flash/nor/tcl: add read_bank and verify_bank
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB JLINK based
453 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
454 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
460 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
464 @end itemize
465
466 @section USB RLINK based
467 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
468 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
469 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
470
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
476 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
477 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
478 @end itemize
479
480 @section USB ST-LINK based
481 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
482 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
483
484 @itemize @bullet
485 @item @b{ST-LINK}
486 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
487 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
488 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
489 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
490 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
491 @end itemize
492
493 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
494 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
495 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
496 @itemize @bullet
497 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
498 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
499 @end itemize
500
501 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
502 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
503 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
504 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
505
506 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
507 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
508 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
509
510 @section USB Other
511 @itemize @bullet
512 @item @b{USBprog}
513 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
514
515 @item @b{USB - Presto}
516 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
517
518 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
519 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
520
521 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
522 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
523
524 @item @b{Buspirate}
525 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
526
527 @item @b{opendous}
528 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
529
530 @item @b{estick}
531 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
532
533 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
534 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
535 @end itemize
536
537 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
538
539 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
540 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
541 these on the market.
542
543 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
544 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
545 of USB-based ones.
546
547 @itemize @bullet
548
549 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
550 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
551
552 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
553 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
554 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
555
556 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Wiggler2}
560 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
561
562 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
563 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
564
565 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
566 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
567
568 @item @b{arm-jtag}
569 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
570
571 @item @b{chameleon}
572 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
573
574 @item @b{Triton}
575 @* Unknown.
576
577 @item @b{Lattice}
578 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
579 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
580
581 @item @b{flashlink}
582 @* From ST Microsystems;
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
584
585 @end itemize
586
587 @section Other...
588 @itemize @bullet
589
590 @item @b{ep93xx}
591 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
592
593 @item @b{at91rm9200}
594 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
595
596 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
597 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
598
599 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
600 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
601 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
602
603 @end itemize
604
605 @node About Jim-Tcl
606 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex Jim-Tcl
608 @cindex tcl
609
610 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
611 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
612 command interpreter.
613
614 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
615 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
616 much of anything about Tcl.
617 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
618
619 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
620 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
621 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
622 OpenOCD mailing list.
623
624 @itemize @bullet
625 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
626 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
627 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
628 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
629 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
630 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
631
632 @item @b{Missing Features}
633 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
634 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
635 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
636 enabled in OpenOCD.
637
638 @item @b{Scripts}
639 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
640 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
641 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
642
643 @item @b{Commands}
644 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
645 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
646 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
647 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
648
649 @item @b{Historical Note}
650 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
651 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
652 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
653 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
654
655 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
656 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
657 @end itemize
658
659 @node Running
660 @chapter Running
661 @cindex command line options
662 @cindex logfile
663 @cindex directory search
664
665 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
666 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
667 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
668 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
669 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
670 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
671 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
672
673 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
674 tell it how each debug session should work.
675 The @option{--help} option shows:
676 @verbatim
677 bash$ openocd --help
678
679 --help | -h display this help
680 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
681 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
682 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
683 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
684 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
685 --command | -c run <command>
686 @end verbatim
687
688 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
689 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
690 To specify one or more different
691 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
692
693 @example
694 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
695 @end example
696
697 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
698 @enumerate
699 @item the current directory,
700 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
701 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
702 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Daemon Configuration
1998 @chapter Daemon Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129 @end deffn
2130
2131 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2132 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2133 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2134 output from the Tcl engine.
2135 Intended as a machine interface.
2136 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2137 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2138
2139 @end deffn
2140
2141 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2142 Specify or query the
2143 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2144 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2145 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2146 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2147 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2148 @end deffn
2149
2150 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2151 @section GDB Configuration
2152 @cindex GDB
2153 @cindex GDB configuration
2154 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2155 The ones listed here are static and global.
2156 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2157 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2158
2159 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2160 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2161 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2162 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2163 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2164 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2165 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2166 @end deffn
2167
2168 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2169 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2170 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2171 vFlash packet is received.
2172 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2173 @end deffn
2174
2175 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2176 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2177 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2178 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2179 for flash programming to work.
2180 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2181 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2182 @end deffn
2183
2184 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2185 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2186 by GDB memory read packets.
2187 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2188 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2189 @end deffn
2190
2191 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2192 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2193 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2197 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2198
2199 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2200 @end deffn
2201
2202 @anchor{eventpolling}
2203 @section Event Polling
2204
2205 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2206 where significant events can happen at any time.
2207 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2208 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2209 or to GDB.
2210
2211 Examples of such events include:
2212
2213 @itemize
2214 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2215 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2216 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2217 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2218 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2219 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2220 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2221 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2222 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2223 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2224 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2225 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2226 @end itemize
2227
2228 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2229 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2230 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2231 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2232 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2233
2234 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2235 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2236 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2237 to the various active targets.
2238 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2239 which is normally done in the background.
2240
2241 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2242 Poll the current target for its current state.
2243 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2244 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2245 specific information about the current state is printed.
2246 An optional parameter
2247 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2248
2249 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2250 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2251 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2252 @example
2253 > poll
2254 background polling: on
2255 target state: halted
2256 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2257 current mode: Supervisor
2258 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2259 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2260 >
2261 @end example
2262 @end deffn
2263
2264 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2265 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2266 @cindex config file, interface
2267 @cindex interface config file
2268
2269 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2270 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2271 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2272
2273 @quotation Note
2274 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2275 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2276 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2277 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2278 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2279 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2280 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2281 @end quotation
2282
2283 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2284 through commands in an interface configuration
2285 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2286 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2287
2288 @example
2289 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2290 @end example
2291
2292 These commands tell
2293 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2294 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2295
2296 @example
2297 # jlink interface
2298 interface jlink
2299 @end example
2300
2301 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2302
2303
2304 @section Interface Configuration
2305
2306 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2307 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2308 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2309
2310 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2311 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2312 target.
2313 @end deffn
2314
2315 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2316 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2317 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2318 @end deffn
2319 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2320 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2321 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2322 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2323 the hardware can support.
2324 @end deffn
2325
2326
2327
2328 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2329 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2330 @end deffn
2331
2332 @section Interface Drivers
2333
2334 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2335 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2336 available at run time.
2337
2338 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2339 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2340 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2341 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2342
2343 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2344 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2345 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2346 @end deffn
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2349 Displays status of RTCK option.
2350 Optionally sets that option first.
2351 @end deffn
2352 @end deffn
2353
2354 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2355 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2356 This has one driver-specific command:
2357
2358 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2359 Logs some status
2360 @end deffn
2361 @end deffn
2362
2363 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2364 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2365 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2366 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2367 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2368 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2372 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2373
2374 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2375 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2376 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2377 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2378 @example
2379 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2380 @end example
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2384 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2385 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2389 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2390 @end deffn
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2394 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2395 @end deffn
2396
2397 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2398 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2402 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2403
2404 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2405 recommended as its replacement.
2406
2407 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2408 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2409
2410 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2411 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2412 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2413 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2414 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2418 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2419 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2420 is connected to the host.
2421 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2422 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2423 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2424 @end deffn
2425
2426 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2427 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2428 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2429 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2432 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2433 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2434 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2435 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2436 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2437 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2438 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2439 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2440 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2441 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2442 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2443 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2444 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2445 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2446 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2447 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2448 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2449 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2450 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2451 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2452 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2453 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2454 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2455 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2456 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2457 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2458 @end itemize
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2462 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2463 default values are used.
2464 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2465 @example
2466 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2467 @end example
2468 @end deffn
2469
2470 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2471 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2472 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2473 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2474 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2475 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2476 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2477 @end deffn
2478
2479 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2480 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2481 The default value is 1.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 For example, the interface config file for a
2485 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2486
2487 @example
2488 interface ft2232
2489 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2490 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2491 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2492 @end example
2493 @end deffn
2494
2495 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2496 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2497 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2498 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2499 interface driver.
2500
2501 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2502 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2503 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2504
2505 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2506 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2507 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2508
2509 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2510 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2511 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2512 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2513 will be used for their customary purpose.
2514
2515 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2516 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2517 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2518 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2519
2520 @itemize @minus
2521 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2522 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2523 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2524 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2525 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2526 switching data and direction as necessary
2527 @end itemize
2528
2529 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2530 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2531
2532 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2533 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2534 default values are used.
2535 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2536 @example
2537 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2538 @end example
2539 @end deffn
2540
2541 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2542 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2543 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2544 during device selection.
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2548 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2549 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2550 is connected to the host.
2551 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2552 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2553 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2554 @end deffn
2555
2556 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2557 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2558 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2562 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2563 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2564 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2565 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2566 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2567 and initially asserted reset signals.
2568 @end deffn
2569
2570 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2571 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2572 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2573 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2574 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2575 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2576 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2577 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2578 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2579
2580 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2581 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2582 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2583 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2584 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2585 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2586
2587 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2588 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2589 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2590 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2591 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2592 are always driven by the FTDI.
2593
2594 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2595 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2596 @var{name}.
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2600 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2601 @itemize @minus
2602 @item @option{0}, drive low
2603 @item @option{1}, drive high
2604 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2605 @end itemize
2606 @end deffn
2607
2608 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2609 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2610 @end deffn
2611
2612 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2613 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2614 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2615 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2616
2617 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2618 processors which are being simulated.
2619
2620 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2621 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2622 sockets instead of TCP.
2623 @end deffn
2624
2625 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2626 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2627 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2631 something like:
2632
2633 @example
2634 interface remote_bitbang
2635 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2636 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2637 @end example
2638
2639 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2640 named mysocket:
2641
2642 @example
2643 interface remote_bitbang
2644 remote_bitbang_port 0
2645 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2646 @end example
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2650 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2651 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2652 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2655 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2656 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2657 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2658 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2662 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2663 default values are used.
2664 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2665 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2666 @example
2667 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2668 @end example
2669 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2670 @example
2671 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2672 @end example
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2676 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2677 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2678 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2679 target board.
2680
2681 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2682 @example
2683 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2684 reset_config srst_only
2685 @end example
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ftd2xx}|@option{ublast2})
2689 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2690 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2691 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2695 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2696 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2697 @end deffn
2698
2699 @end deffn
2700
2701 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2702 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2703 This has one driver-specific command:
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2706 Display either the address of the I/O port
2707 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2708 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2709 This is a write-once setting.
2710 @end deffn
2711 @end deffn
2712
2713 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2714 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2715
2716 @quotation Compatibility Note
2717 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2718 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2719 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2720 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2721 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2722 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2723 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2724 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2725 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2726 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2727 @end quotation
2728
2729 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2730 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2731 @end deffn
2732 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2733 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2734 @end deffn
2735 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2736 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2737 @end deffn
2738 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2739 Display the J-Link configuration.
2740 @end deffn
2741 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2742 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2743 @end deffn
2744 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2745 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2746 @end deffn
2747 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2748 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2749 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2750 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2751 @end deffn
2752 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2753 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2754 @end deffn
2755 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2756 Reset the current configuration.
2757 @end deffn
2758 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2759 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2760 @end deffn
2761 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2762 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2763 @end deffn
2764 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} serial-number
2765 Set the @var{serial-number} of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected to the host.
2766 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2767
2768 Note that there may be leading zeros in the @var{serial-number} string
2769 that will not show in the Segger software, but must be specified here.
2770 Debug level 3 output contains serial numbers if there is a mismatch.
2771
2772 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2773 @end deffn
2774 @end deffn
2775
2776 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2777 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2778 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2779 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2780 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2781
2782 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2783 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2784 This is a write-once setting.
2785 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2786
2787 @itemize @minus
2788 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2789 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2790 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2791 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2792 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2793 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2794 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2795 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2796 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2797 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2798 some versions of
2799 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2800 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2801 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2802 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2803 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2804 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2805 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2806 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2807 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2808 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2809 @end itemize
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2813 Display either the address of the I/O port
2814 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2815 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2816 This is a write-once setting.
2817
2818 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2819 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2820 you may encounter a problem.
2821 @end deffn
2822
2823 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2824 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2825 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2826 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2827 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2828 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2829
2830 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2831 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2832 @quotation Tip
2833 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2834 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2835 @example
2836 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2837 > adapter_khz 500
2838 @end example
2839 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2840 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2841 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2842 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2843 large set of samples.
2844 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2845 @example
2846 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2847 @end example
2848 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2849 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2850
2851 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2852 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2853 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2854 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2855 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2856 @end quotation
2857 @end deffn
2858
2859 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2860 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2861 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2862 @end deffn
2863
2864 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2865 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2866
2867 @example
2868 interface parport
2869 parport_port 0x278
2870 parport_cable wiggler
2871 @end example
2872 @end deffn
2873
2874 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2875 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2876 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2877 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2878 @end deffn
2879 @end deffn
2880
2881 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2882 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2883 @end deffn
2884
2885 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2886 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2887 @end deffn
2888
2889 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2890 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2891
2892 @quotation Note
2893 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2894 which are not currently documented here.
2895 @end quotation
2896 @end deffn
2897
2898 @anchor{hla_interface}
2899 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2900 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2901 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2902 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2903
2904 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2905 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2906 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2907 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2908 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2909
2910 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2911 Currently Not Supported.
2912 @end deffn
2913
2914 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2915 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2916 @end deffn
2917
2918 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2919 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2923 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2924 @end deffn
2925
2926 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2927 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2928 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2929 @end deffn
2930 @end deffn
2931
2932 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2933 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2934 @end deffn
2935
2936 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2937 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2938 @end deffn
2939
2940 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2941 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2942 @end deffn
2943
2944 @quotation Note
2945 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2946 which are not currently documented here.
2947 @end quotation
2948
2949 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2950 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2951 No arguments: print status.
2952 @end deffn
2953
2954 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2955 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2956 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2957
2958 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2959 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2960 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2961 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2962 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2963 configuration on exit.
2964
2965 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2966 pinout.
2967
2968 @end deffn
2969
2970 @section Transport Configuration
2971 @cindex Transport
2972 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2973 and the debug adapter you are using,
2974 several transports may be available to
2975 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2976 @deffn Command {transport list}
2977 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2978 version of OpenOCD.
2979 @end deffn
2980
2981 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2982 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2983
2984 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2985 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2986 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2987 adapter's driver).
2988
2989 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2990 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2991 supported by the debug adapter.
2992
2993 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2994 transport, if any.
2995 @end deffn
2996
2997 @subsection JTAG Transport
2998 @cindex JTAG
2999 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3000 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3001 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3002 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3003 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3004 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3005
3006 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3007 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3008 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3009 hla_jtag}.
3010
3011 @subsection SWD Transport
3012 @cindex SWD
3013 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3014 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3015 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3016 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3017 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3018 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3019 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3020
3021 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3022 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3023 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3024 hla_swd}.
3025
3026 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3027 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3028 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3029 expected to change.
3030 @end deffn
3031 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3032 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3033 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3034 No parameters: displays current settings.
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 @subsection SPI Transport
3038 @cindex SPI
3039 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3040 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3041 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3042 solution for flash programming.
3043
3044 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3045 @section JTAG Speed
3046 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3047 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3048 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3049 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3050 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3051 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3052 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3053 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3054 power management software that may be active.
3055
3056 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3057 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3058 target event handler.
3059 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3060 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3061 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3062 sets up those clocks).
3063 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3064 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3065 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3066 in the target config file.
3067 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3068 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3069 config file instead.
3070 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3071 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3072 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3073
3074 @example
3075 jtag_rclk 3000
3076 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3077 @end example
3078
3079 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3080 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3081 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3082 may not be the fastest solution.
3083
3084 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3085 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3086 which support adaptive clocking.
3087
3088 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3089 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3090 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3091 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3092 than the speed specified.
3093
3094 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3095 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3096 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3097 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3098
3099 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3100 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3101 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3102 JTAG clocking after setup.
3103 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3104 If the interface device can not
3105 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3106 @end deffn
3107
3108 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3109 @cindex adaptive clocking
3110 @cindex RTCK
3111 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3112 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3113 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3114 @example
3115 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3116 jtag_rclk 3000
3117 @end example
3118 @end defun
3119
3120 @node Reset Configuration
3121 @chapter Reset Configuration
3122 @cindex Reset Configuration
3123
3124 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3125 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3126 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3127 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3128 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3129 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3130 Please see the various board files for examples.
3131
3132 @quotation Note
3133 To maintainers and integrators:
3134 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3135 Normally the board configuration file
3136 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3137 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3138
3139 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3140 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3141 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3142 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3143 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3144 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3145 @end quotation
3146
3147 @section Types of Reset
3148
3149 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3150 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3151 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3152
3153 @itemize @bullet
3154 @item
3155 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3156 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3157 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3158 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3159 @item
3160 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3161 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3162 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3163 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3164 @item
3165 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3166 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3167 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3168 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3169 @item
3170 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3171 several other types of reset.
3172 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3173 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3174 There may be individual module resets.
3175 @end itemize
3176
3177 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3178 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3179 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3180 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3181 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3182 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3183 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3184 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3185 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3186
3187 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3188 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3189
3190 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3191 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3192 common issues are:
3193
3194 @itemize @bullet
3195
3196 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3197 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3198 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3199 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3200 when either of those signals is not connected.
3201 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3202 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3203 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3204 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3205
3206 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3207 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3208 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3209 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3210
3211 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3212 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3213 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3214 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3215 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3216 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3217 hardware debouncing.
3218 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3219 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3220
3221 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3222 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3223 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3224 to use push/pull output drivers.
3225 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3226 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3227 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3228 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3229
3230 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3231 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3232 issues (not limited to errata).
3233 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3234 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3235 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3236 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3237 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3238 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3239 @end itemize
3240
3241 There can also be other issues.
3242 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3243 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3244 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3245 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3246 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3247 Agreement (NDA).
3248
3249 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3250 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3251 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3252
3253 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3254 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3255
3256 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3257
3258 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3259 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3260 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3261 allowing it to be deasserted.
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3265 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3266 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3267 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3268 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3272 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3273 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3274 allowing it to be deasserted.
3275 @end deffn
3276
3277 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3278 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3279 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3283 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3284 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3285 configuration scripts.
3286
3287 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3288 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3289 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3290 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3291 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3292 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3293 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3294 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3295
3296 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3297 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3298 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3299 -- may be specified at a time.
3300 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3301 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3302 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3303 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3304 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3305
3306 @itemize
3307 @item
3308 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3309 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3310 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3311 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3312 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3313
3314 @quotation Tip
3315 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3316 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3317 @end quotation
3318
3319 @item
3320 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3321 signal implementations.
3322 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3323 indicating everything behaves normally.
3324 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3325 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3326 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3327 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3328 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3329 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3330 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3331
3332 @item
3333 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3334 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3335 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3336 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3337 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3338 while SRST is asserted.
3339 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3340 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3341
3342 @item
3343 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3344 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3345 is required to use this option.
3346 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3347 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3348 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3349 be asserted before any target connection.
3350 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3351 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3352 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3353 @end itemize
3354
3355 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3356 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3357 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3358 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3359 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3360
3361 @itemize
3362 @item
3363 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3364 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3365 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3366 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3367
3368 @item
3369 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3370 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3371 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3372 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3373 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3374 @end itemize
3375 @end deffn
3376
3377 @section Custom Reset Handling
3378 @cindex events
3379
3380 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3381 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3382 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3383 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3384 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3385 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3386
3387 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3388 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3389 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3390 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3391 want to reset everything at once.
3392
3393 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3394 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3395 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3396 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3397 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3398 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3399 needs special attention.
3400
3401 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3402 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3403 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3404 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3405 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3406 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3407 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3408 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3409
3410 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3411 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3412 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3413 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3414 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3415
3416 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3417 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3418 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3419 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3420 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3421 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3422 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3423 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3424 or potentially some other value.
3425
3426 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3427 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3428 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3429 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3430 (or their associated targets)
3431 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3432
3433 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3434 they return.
3435 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3436 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3437 @end deffn
3438
3439 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3440 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3441 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3442 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3443 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3444 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3445 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3446 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3447 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3448 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3449 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3450 @end deffn
3451
3452 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3453 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3454 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3455 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3456 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3457 @end deffn
3458
3459
3460 @node TAP Declaration
3461 @chapter TAP Declaration
3462 @cindex TAP declaration
3463 @cindex TAP configuration
3464
3465 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3466 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3467
3468 @itemize @bullet
3469 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3470 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3471 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3472 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3473 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3474 start running that code.
3475 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3476 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3477 and missing connections.
3478 @end itemize
3479
3480 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3481 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3482 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3483 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3484 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3485
3486 @section Scan Chains
3487 @cindex scan chain
3488
3489 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3490 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3491 They also need to be added to
3492 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3493 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3494 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3495 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3496 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3497 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3498 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3499 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3500
3501 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3502 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3503 command, presented in the next chapter.
3504 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3505 debugging targets.)
3506 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3507
3508 @verbatim
3509 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3510 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3511 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3512 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3513 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3514 @end verbatim
3515
3516 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3517 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3518 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3519 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3520 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3521 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3522 until they are told to do so.
3523
3524 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3525 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3526 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3527 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3528
3529 @example
3530 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3531 @end example
3532
3533 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3534 by a given chip.
3535 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3536 and so forth.
3537 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3538 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3539 both inside a single chip and between them.
3540 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3541
3542 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3543 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3544 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3545 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3546 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3547 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3548 includes commands something like this:
3549
3550 @example
3551 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3552 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3553 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3554 @end example
3555
3556 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3557 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3558 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3559
3560 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3561 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3562 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3563 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3564 @example
3565 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3566 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3567 @}
3568 @end example
3569 @end deffn
3570
3571 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3572 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3573 and their status.
3574 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3575 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3576 but systems with a JTAG router can
3577 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3578 @end deffn
3579
3580 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3581 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3582
3583 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3584 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3585
3586 @section TAP Names
3587 @cindex dotted name
3588
3589 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3590 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3591 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3592 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3593 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3594 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3595 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3596 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3597
3598 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3599 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3600 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3601
3602 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3603
3604 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3605 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3606 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3607 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3608
3609 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3610 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3611 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3612 overridable.
3613
3614 @cindex TAP naming convention
3615 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3616 and should follow this convention:
3617
3618 @itemize @bullet
3619 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3620 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3621 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3622 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3623 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3624 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3625 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3626 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3627 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3628 with a single TAP;
3629 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3630 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3631 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3632 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3633 @end itemize
3634
3635 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3636
3637 @itemize @bullet
3638 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3639 @*The length in bits of the
3640 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3641 @end itemize
3642
3643 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3644
3645 @itemize @bullet
3646 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3647 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3648 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3649 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3650 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3651 (the TAP is linked in).
3652 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3653 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3654 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3655 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3656 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3657 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3658 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3659 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3660 values that were found but not included in the list.
3661
3662 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3663 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3664 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3665 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3666 hardware to find these values.
3667 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3668 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3669 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3670 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3671 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3672 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3673 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3674 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3675 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3676 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3677 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3678 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3679 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3680 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3681 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3682 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3683 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3684 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3685 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3686 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3687 @end itemize
3688 @end deffn
3689
3690 @section Other TAP commands
3691
3692 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3693 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3694 At this writing this TAP attribute
3695 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3696 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3697 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3698 See the next section for information about the available events.
3699
3700 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3701 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3702 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3703 @end deffn
3704
3705 @section TAP Events
3706 @cindex events
3707 @cindex TAP events
3708
3709 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3710 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3711 The other applies to debugger targets,
3712 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3713
3714 The TAP events currently defined are:
3715
3716 @itemize @bullet
3717 @item @b{post-reset}
3718 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3719 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3720 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3721 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3722 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3723
3724 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3725 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3726 of any particular target.
3727 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3728 @item @b{setup}
3729 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3730 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3731 @item @b{tap-disable}
3732 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3733 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3734 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3735 @item @b{tap-enable}
3736 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3737 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3738 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3739 @end itemize
3740
3741 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3742 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3743 contents to be accurate), you might:
3744
3745 @example
3746 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3747 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3748 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3749 @}
3750 @end example
3751
3752
3753 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3754 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3755 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3756 @cindex jrc
3757
3758 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3759 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3760 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3761 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3762 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3763
3764 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3765 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3766 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3767 be visible.
3768 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3769 ignores, such as:
3770
3771 @itemize
3772 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3773 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3774 TAPs receive new instructions.
3775 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3776 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3777 @end itemize
3778
3779 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3780 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3781 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3782 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3783
3784 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3785 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3786
3787 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3788 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3789 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3790 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3791 should define TAP event handlers using
3792 code that looks something like this:
3793
3794 @example
3795 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3796 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3797 @}
3798 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3799 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3800 @}
3801 @end example
3802
3803 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3804
3805 @example
3806 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3807 @end example
3808
3809 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3810 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3811 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3812 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3813
3814 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3815 If necessary, disables the tap
3816 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3817 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3818 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3819 and "0" if it is disabled.
3820 @end deffn
3821
3822 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3823 If necessary, enables the tap
3824 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3825 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3826 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3827 and "0" if it is disabled.
3828 @end deffn
3829
3830 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3831 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3832 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3833 and "0" if it is disabled.
3834
3835 @quotation Note
3836 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3837 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3838 @end quotation
3839 @end deffn
3840
3841 @anchor{autoprobing}
3842 @section Autoprobing
3843 @cindex autoprobe
3844 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3845
3846 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3847 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3848 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3849 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3850
3851 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3852 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3853 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3854 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3855 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3856 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3857 right when they come out of reset).
3858
3859 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3860
3861 @example
3862 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3863 reset_config trst_and_srst
3864 jtag_rclk 8
3865 @end example
3866
3867 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3868 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3869
3870 @enumerate
3871 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3872 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3873 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3874 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3875 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3876 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3877 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3878 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3879 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3880 that is discovered.
3881 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3882 register, it will report it.
3883 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3884 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3885 @end enumerate
3886
3887 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3888 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3889 that's a bit more complex:
3890
3891 @example
3892 clock speed 8 kHz
3893 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3894 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3895 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3896 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3897 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3898 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3899 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3900 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3901 @end example
3902
3903 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3904 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3905 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3906 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3907 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3908 and so forth.
3909
3910 @node CPU Configuration
3911 @chapter CPU Configuration
3912 @cindex GDB target
3913
3914 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3915 You can also access these targets without GDB
3916 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3917 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3918 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3919 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3920
3921 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3922 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3923
3924 @section Target List
3925 @cindex target, current
3926 @cindex target, list
3927
3928 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3929 where each member has a name.
3930 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3931 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3932 (plural!) command.
3933 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3934 look like with more than one:
3935 @verbatim
3936 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3937 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3938 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3939 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3940 @end verbatim
3941
3942 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3943 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3944 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3945 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3946 space seen by that current target.
3947 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3948 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3949 are examples; and there are many more.
3950
3951 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3952
3953 @deffn Command {target current}
3954 Returns the name of the current target.
3955 @end deffn
3956
3957 @deffn Command {target names}
3958 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3959 @example
3960 foreach t [target names] @{
3961 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3962 @}
3963 @end example
3964 @end deffn
3965
3966 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3967 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3968
3969 @deffn Command targets [name]
3970 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3971 command names are singular.}
3972
3973 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3974 targets in a user friendly form.
3975
3976 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3977 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3978 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3979 @end deffn
3980
3981 @section Target CPU Types
3982 @cindex target type
3983 @cindex CPU type
3984
3985 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3986 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3987 when calling @command{target create}.
3988 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3989 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3990 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3991 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3992 what core-specific commands may be available
3993 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3994 and more.
3995
3996 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
3997 since there's a command to list them.
3998
3999 @anchor{targettypes}
4000 @deffn Command {target types}
4001 Lists all supported target types.
4002 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4003
4004 @itemize @bullet
4005 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4006 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4007 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4008 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4009 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4010 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4011 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4012 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4013 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4014 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4015 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4016 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4017 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4018 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4019 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4020 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4021 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4022 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4023 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4024 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4025 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4026 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4027 @itemize @minus
4028 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4029 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4030 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4031 @end itemize
4032 And two debug interfaces cores:
4033 @itemize @minus
4034 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4035 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4036 @end itemize
4037 @end itemize
4038 @end deffn
4039
4040 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4041 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4042 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4043 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4044 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4045 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4046 reflect design generations;
4047 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4048 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4049
4050 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4051 @section Target Configuration
4052
4053 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4054 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4055 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4056 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4057 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4058
4059 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4060 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4061 optional parts.
4062 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4063 command, created as part of target creation.
4064
4065 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4066 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4067 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4068 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4069 to be much more board-specific.
4070 The key steps you use might look something like this
4071
4072 @example
4073 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4074 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4075 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4076 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4077 @end example
4078
4079 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4080 on-chip SRAM.
4081 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4082 writes to target memory;
4083 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4084 GDB memory checksumming;
4085 and more.
4086
4087 @quotation Warning
4088 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4089 inaccessible when application code
4090 (such as an operating system)
4091 enables or disables the MMU.
4092 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4093 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4094 easy access to other addresses needed.
4095 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4096 @end quotation
4097
4098 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4099 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4100 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4101 controllers.
4102 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4103 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4104 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4105
4106 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4107 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4108 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4109 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4110 purposes including additional configuration.
4111
4112 @itemize @bullet
4113 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4114 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4115 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4116 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4117
4118 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4119 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4120 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4121 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4122 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4123 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4124 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4125
4126 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4127 @end itemize
4128 @end deffn
4129
4130 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4131 The options accepted by this command may also be
4132 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4133 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4134 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4135
4136 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4137 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4138 and changing its endianness.
4139
4140 @itemize @bullet
4141
4142 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4143 used to access this target.
4144
4145 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4146 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4147
4148 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4149 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4150 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4151 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4152 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4153 same event name assigns only one handler.
4154
4155 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4156 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4157 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4158 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4159 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4160 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4161 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4162
4163 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4164 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4165 or virtual address is being used.
4166
4167 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4168 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4169
4170 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4171 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4172 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4173 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4174 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4175
4176 @anchor{rtostype}
4177 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4178 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4179 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4180 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4181
4182 @end itemize
4183 @end deffn
4184
4185 @section Other $target_name Commands
4186 @cindex object command
4187
4188 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4189 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4190
4191 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4192 Once a button is created a button
4193 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4194 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4195 configure it like this:
4196
4197 @example
4198 # Create
4199 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4200 # Modify
4201 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4202 # Query
4203 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4204 # Report
4205 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4206 @end example
4207
4208 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4209 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4210
4211 @example
4212 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4213 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4214 @end example
4215
4216 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4217
4218 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4219 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4220 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4221 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4222 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4223 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4224 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4225 They are not otherwise documented here.
4226 @end deffn
4227
4228 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4229 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4230 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4231 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4232 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4233 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4234 the target side uses raw memory.
4235
4236 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4237 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4238 The script orientation comes from working with data
4239 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4240 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4241 and neither store nor return those values.
4242
4243 @itemize
4244 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4245 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4246 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4247 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4248 @end itemize
4249 @end deffn
4250
4251 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4252 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4253 @command{$target_name configure}
4254 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4255 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4256 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4257 There are a few special cases:
4258
4259 @itemize @bullet
4260 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4261 event named @var{event_name}.
4262 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4263 two parameters.
4264 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4265 This is a special case because this is set using
4266 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4267 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4268 @end itemize
4269
4270 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4271 all the targets you might use something like this:
4272
4273 @example
4274 foreach name [target names] @{
4275 set y [$name cget -endian]
4276 set z [$name cget -type]
4277 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4278 $x $name $y $z]
4279 @}
4280 @end example
4281 @end deffn
4282
4283 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4284 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4285 Displays the current target state:
4286 @code{debug-running},
4287 @code{halted},
4288 @code{reset},
4289 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4290 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4291 @end deffn
4292
4293 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4294 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4295 currently associated with this target.
4296 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4297 @end deffn
4298
4299 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4300 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4301 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4302 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4303 @end deffn
4304
4305 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4306 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4307 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4308 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4309 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4310 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4311 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4312 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4313 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4314 @end deffn
4315
4316 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4317 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4318 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4319 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4320 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4321 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4322 @end deffn
4323
4324 @anchor{targetevents}
4325 @section Target Events
4326 @cindex target events
4327 @cindex events
4328 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4329 For example:
4330 @itemize @bullet
4331 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4332 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4333 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4334 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4335 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4336 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4337 to set up system clocks or
4338 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4339 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4340 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4341 @end itemize
4342
4343 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4344 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4345 @command{target create ... -event}.
4346
4347 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4348 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4349 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4350
4351 @example
4352 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4353 echo "Reset..."
4354 reset halt
4355 @}
4356 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4357 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4358 echo "Reset..."
4359 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4360 # we need a reset init.
4361 reset init
4362 @}
4363 @end example
4364
4365 The following target events are defined:
4366
4367 @itemize @bullet
4368 @item @b{debug-halted}
4369 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4370 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4371 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4372 @item @b{early-halted}
4373 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4374 @item @b{examine-start}
4375 @* Before target examine is called.
4376 @item @b{examine-end}
4377 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4378 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4379 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4380 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4381 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4382 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4383 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4384 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4385 @* When GDB disconnects
4386 @item @b{gdb-end}
4387 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4388 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4389 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4390 @code{reset init})
4391 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4392 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4393 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4394 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4395 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4396 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4397 @item @b{gdb-start}
4398 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4399 @item @b{halted}
4400 @* The target has halted
4401 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4402 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4403 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4404 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4405 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4406 @item @b{reset-assert}
4407 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4408 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4409 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4410 it instead of asserting SRST.
4411 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4412 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4413 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4414 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4415 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4416 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4417 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4418 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4419 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4420 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4421 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4422 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4423 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4424 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4425 released on the scan chain.
4426 @item @b{reset-end}
4427 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4428 @ignore
4429 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4430 @* Currently not used
4431 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4432 @* Currently not used
4433 @end ignore
4434 @item @b{reset-init}
4435 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4436 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4437
4438 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4439 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4440 multiplexing, and so on.
4441 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4442 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4443 @item @b{reset-start}
4444 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4445 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4446
4447 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4448 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4449 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4450 @ignore
4451 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4452 @* Currently not used
4453 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4454 @* Currently not used
4455 @end ignore
4456 @item @b{resume-start}
4457 @* Before any target is resumed
4458 @item @b{resume-end}
4459 @* After all targets have resumed
4460 @item @b{resumed}
4461 @* Target has resumed
4462 @item @b{trace-config}
4463 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4464 @end itemize
4465
4466 @node Flash Commands
4467 @chapter Flash Commands
4468
4469 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4470 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4471 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4472 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4473 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4474 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4475 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4476 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4477 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4478
4479 Flash Steps:
4480 @enumerate
4481 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4482 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4483 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4484 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4485 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4486 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4487 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4488 @item GDB Flashing
4489 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4490 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4491 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4492 @end enumerate
4493
4494 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4495 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4496 so that it can't boot.
4497 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4498 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4499
4500 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4501 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4502 @cindex flash configuration
4503
4504 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4505 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4506 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4507 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4508 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4509 see the driver-specific documentation.
4510
4511 @itemize @bullet
4512 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4513 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4514 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4515 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4516 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4517 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4518 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4519 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4520 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4521 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4522 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4523 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4524 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4525 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4526 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4527 commands to the flash controller.
4528 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4529 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4530 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4531 for more information.
4532 @end itemize
4533 @quotation Note
4534 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4535 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4536 @end quotation
4537 @end deffn
4538
4539 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4540 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4541 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4542 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4543 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4544 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4545 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4546 @end deffn
4547
4548 @deffn Command {flash list}
4549 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4550 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4551 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4552 @end deffn
4553
4554 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4555 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4556 depends on the flash type.
4557 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4558 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4559 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4560 but most don't bother.
4561 @end deffn
4562
4563 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4564 @cindex flash erasing
4565 @cindex flash reading
4566 @cindex flash writing
4567 @cindex flash programming
4568 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4569
4570 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4571 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4572 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4573 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4574 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4575
4576 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4577 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4578 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4579 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4580 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4581
4582 @quotation Note
4583 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4584 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4585 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4586 back to a flash bank.
4587 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4588 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4589 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4590 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4591 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4592 @end quotation
4593
4594 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4595 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4596 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4597 disabled first.
4598 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4599 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4600 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4601
4602 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4603 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4604 up to and including @var{last}.
4605 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4606 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4607 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4608 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4609 @end deffn
4610
4611 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4612 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4613 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4614 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4615 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4616 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4617 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4618 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4619 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4620 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4621 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4622 before erase starts.
4623 @end deffn
4624
4625 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4626 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4627 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4628 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4629 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4630 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4631 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4632 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4633 before issuing this command.
4634 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4635 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4636 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4637 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4638 @end deffn
4639 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4640
4641 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4642 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4643 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4644 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4645 @end deffn
4646
4647 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4648 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4649 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4650 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4651 @end deffn
4652
4653 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4654 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4655 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4656 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4657 @end deffn
4658
4659 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4660 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4661 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4662 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4663 to the base address for each section in the image.
4664 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4665 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4666 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4667 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4668 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4669 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4670 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4671 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4672 each image section.
4673
4674 @quotation Warning
4675 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4676 data you want to preserve.
4677 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4678 sections might be erased with no notice.
4679 @itemize
4680 @item
4681 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4682 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4683 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4684 @item
4685 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4686 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4687 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4688 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4689 @end itemize
4690 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4691 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4692 @end quotation
4693
4694 @end deffn
4695
4696 @section Other Flash commands
4697 @cindex flash protection
4698
4699 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4700 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4701 and display that status.
4702 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4703 @end deffn
4704
4705 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4706 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4707 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4708 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4709 and possibly stale information.
4710 @end deffn
4711
4712 @anchor{flashprotect}
4713 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4714 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4715 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4716 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4717 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4718 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4719 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4720 @end deffn
4721
4722 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4723 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4724 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4725 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4726 @end deffn
4727
4728 @anchor{program}
4729 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4730 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4731 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4732 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4733 @end deffn
4734
4735 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4736 @section Flash Driver List
4737 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4738 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4739 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4740
4741 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4742 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4743 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4744
4745 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4746
4747 @itemize
4748 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4749 @end itemize
4750
4751 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4752 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4753 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4754 @example
4755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4756 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4757 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4758 @end example
4759 @end deffn
4760
4761 @subsection External Flash
4762
4763 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4764 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4765 @cindex CFI
4766 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4767 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4768 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4769 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4770 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4771 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4772 configure a bus and its timings), or
4773 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4774 on the flash chip.
4775 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4776 speed up operation.
4777
4778 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4779
4780 @itemize
4781 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4782 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4783 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4784 @end itemize
4785
4786 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4787 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4788
4789 @example
4790 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4791 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4792 @end example
4793
4794 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4795 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4796 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4797
4798 @example
4799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4800 @end example
4801
4802 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4803 @end deffn
4804
4805 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4806 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4807 @cindex SPIFI
4808 @cindex lpcspifi
4809 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4810 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4811 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4812
4813 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4814 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4815 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4816 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4817 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4818
4819 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4820 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4821 are configured by the driver.
4822
4823 @example
4824 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4825 @end example
4826
4827 @end deffn
4828
4829 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4830 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4831 @cindex SMI
4832 @cindex stmsmi
4833 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4834 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4835 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4836 SPI flash devices.
4837 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4838 flash devices can be connected.
4839
4840 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4841 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4842 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4843 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4844 the flash content.
4845
4846 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4847 to identify the memory bank.
4848 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4849 flash size, are detected automatically.
4850
4851 @example
4852 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4853 @end example
4854
4855 @end deffn
4856
4857 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4858 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4859 Microcontroller platform.
4860
4861 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4862 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4863
4864 @example
4865 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4866 @end example
4867
4868 @end deffn
4869
4870 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4871
4872 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4873 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4874 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4875 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4876 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4877 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4878
4879 @example
4880 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4881 @end example
4882 @end deffn
4883
4884 @anchor{at91samd}
4885 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4886 @cindex at91samd
4887
4888 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4889 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4890 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4891 processor to be halted.
4892 @end deffn
4893
4894 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4895 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4896 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4897 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4898 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4899 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4900
4901 @example
4902 at91samd set-security enable
4903 @end example
4904 @end deffn
4905
4906 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4907 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4908 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4909 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4910 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4911 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4912 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4913 in order to disable this feature.
4914
4915 @example
4916 at91samd eeprom
4917 at91samd eeprom 1024
4918 @end example
4919 @end deffn
4920
4921 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4922 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4923 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4924 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4925 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4926 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4927
4928 @example
4929 at91samd bootloader
4930 at91samd bootloader 16384
4931 @end example
4932 @end deffn
4933
4934 @end deffn
4935
4936 @anchor{at91sam3}
4937 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
4938 @cindex at91sam3
4939 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
4940 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
4941 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
4942 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
4943 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
4944 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
4945 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
4946 chips are confirmed.}
4947
4948 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
4949 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
4950 the following fixed locations:
4951
4952 @example
4953 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
4954 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4955 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
4956 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4957 @end example
4958
4959 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
4960 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
4961 to the @command{flash bank} command:
4962
4963 @itemize
4964 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
4965 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
4966 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
4967 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
4968 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
4969 @end itemize
4970
4971 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
4972
4973 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
4974 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
4975 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
4976 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
4977 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
4978 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
4979 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
4980
4981 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
4982 modifies that GPNVM bit.
4983 @end deffn
4984
4985 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
4986 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
4987 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
4988 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
4989 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
4990 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
4991 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
4992 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
4993 @end deffn
4994
4995 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
4996 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
4997 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
4998 @end deffn
4999 @end deffn
5000
5001 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5002 @cindex at91sam4
5003 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5004 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5005 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5006 @end deffn
5007
5008 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5009 @cindex at91sam4l
5010 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5011 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5012 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5013
5014 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5015 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5016 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5017 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5018 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5019 @end deffn
5020 @end deffn
5021
5022 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5023 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5024 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5025 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5026 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5027
5028 @example
5029 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5030 @end example
5031
5032 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5033 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5034
5035 @itemize
5036 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5037 @item @var{banks}
5038 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5039 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5040 @item @var{pages_size}
5041 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5042 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5043 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5044 @end itemize
5045
5046 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5047 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5048 will be autoconfigured.
5049 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5050
5051 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5052 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5053 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5054 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5055 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5056
5057 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5058 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5059 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5060 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5061 are not truly general purpose).
5062 @quotation Note
5063 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5064 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5065 @end quotation
5066 @end deffn
5067 @end deffn
5068
5069 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5070 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5071 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5072 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5073 @end deffn
5074
5075 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5076 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5077 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5078 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5079 autoconfigures itself.
5080 @example
5081 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5082 @end example
5083 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5084 supported.}
5085 @end deffn
5086
5087 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5088 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5089 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5090 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5091 microcontroller families from NXP.
5092
5093 @quotation Note
5094 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5095 driver:
5096 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5097 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5098 @end quotation
5099
5100 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5101 which must appear in the following order:
5102
5103 @itemize
5104 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5105 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5106 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5107 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5108 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5109 LPC43x[2357])
5110 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5111 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5112 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5113 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5114 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5115 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5116 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5117 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5118 at which the core is running
5119 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5120 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5121 @quotation Note
5122 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5123 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5124 However, if you do provide it,
5125 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5126 @end quotation
5127 @end itemize
5128
5129 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5130
5131 @example
5132 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5133 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5134 @end example
5135
5136 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5137 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5138 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5139 @end deffn
5140 @end deffn
5141
5142 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5143 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5144 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5145 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5146 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5147 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5148
5149 @example
5150 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5151 @end example
5152 @end deffn
5153
5154 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5155 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5156 from NXP.
5157
5158 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5159 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5160 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5161 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5162 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5163 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5164 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5165 you start the PLL.
5166
5167 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5168
5169 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5170 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5171 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5172
5173 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5174 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5175 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5176 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5177 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5178 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5179 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5180
5181 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5182 @example
5183 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5184 @end example
5185
5186 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5187 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5188 @code{flash banks} command.
5189
5190 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5191 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5192 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5193 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5194 a known signature.
5195 Example:
5196 @example
5197 lpc2900 signature 0
5198 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5199 @end example
5200 @end deffn
5201
5202 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5203 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5204 saves it to a file in binary format.
5205 Example:
5206 @example
5207 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5208 @end example
5209 @end deffn
5210
5211 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5212 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5213 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5214 command:
5215
5216 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5217 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5218 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5219 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5220
5221 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5222 Example:
5223 @example
5224 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5225 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5226 @end example
5227 @end deffn
5228
5229 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5230 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5231 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5232 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5233 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5234 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5235 912 bytes.
5236 @quotation Attention
5237 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5238 @end quotation
5239 Example:
5240 @example
5241 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5242 @end example
5243 @end deffn
5244
5245 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5246 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5247 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5248 after the next power cycle.
5249 @quotation Attention
5250 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5251 @end quotation
5252 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5253 Example:
5254 @example
5255 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5256 flash info 0
5257 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5258 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5259 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5260 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5261 @end example
5262 @end deffn
5263
5264 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5265 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5266 effective after the next power cycle.
5267 @quotation Attention
5268 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5269 @end quotation
5270 Examples:
5271 @example
5272 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5273 @end example
5274 @end deffn
5275 @end deffn
5276
5277 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5278 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5279 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5280
5281 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5282 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5283 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5284 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5285
5286 @example
5287 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5288 @end example
5289 @end deffn
5290
5291 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5292 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5293 and integrate flash memory.
5294
5295 @example
5296 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5297 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5298 @end example
5299
5300 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5301 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5302 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5303 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5304 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5305 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5306 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5307 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5308 @end deffn
5309 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5310 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5311 This will remove any Code Protection.
5312 @end deffn
5313 @end deffn
5314
5315 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5316 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5317 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5318 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5319 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5320
5321 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5322 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5323
5324 @example
5325 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5326 @end example
5327
5328 psoc4-specific commands
5329 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5330 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5331
5332 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5333 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5334
5335 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5336 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5337 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5338
5339 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5340 @end deffn
5341
5342 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5343 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5344
5345 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5346 @end deffn
5347 @end deffn
5348
5349 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5350 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5351 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5352 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5353 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5354 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5355 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5356 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5357
5358 @example
5359 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5360 @end example
5361
5362 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5363 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5364 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5365 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5366 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5367 disabled.
5368
5369 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5370 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5371 @quotation Warning
5372 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5373 applied to all of them.
5374 @end quotation
5375 @end deffn
5376 @end deffn
5377
5378 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5379 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5380 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5381 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5382 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5383
5384 @example
5385 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5386 @end example
5387
5388 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5389 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5390 the flash driver.
5391
5392 @example
5393 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5394 @end example
5395
5396 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5397 as per the following example.
5398 @example
5399 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5400 @end example
5401
5402 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5403 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5404 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5405 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5406 are defined:
5407
5408 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5409 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5410 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5411 @end deffn
5412
5413 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5414 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5415 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5416 @end deffn
5417
5418 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5419 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5420 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5421 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5422 @end deffn
5423
5424 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5425 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5426 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5427 @end deffn
5428 @end deffn
5429
5430 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5431 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5432 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5433 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5434 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5435
5436 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5437 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5438 the flash driver.
5439
5440 @example
5441 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5442 @end example
5443
5444 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5445
5446 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5447 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5448 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5449 @end deffn
5450
5451 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5452 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5453 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5454 @end deffn
5455 @end deffn
5456
5457 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5458 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5459 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5460 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5461 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5462
5463 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5464 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5465 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5466 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5467 second bank.
5468
5469 @example
5470 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5471 @end example
5472
5473 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5474
5475 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5476 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5477 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5478 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5479 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5480 @end deffn
5481 @end deffn
5482
5483 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5484 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5485 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5486 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5487 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5488
5489 @example
5490 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5491 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5492 @end example
5493
5494 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5495 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5496 for the specified flash bank.
5497 @end deffn
5498 @end deffn
5499
5500 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5501 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5502 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5503 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5504 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5505
5506 @example
5507 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5508 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5509 @end example
5510
5511 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5512 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5513 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5514
5515 @itemize @bullet
5516 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5517 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5518 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5519 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5520 @end itemize
5521 @end deffn
5522
5523 @end deffn
5524
5525 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5526 @cindex str9xpec
5527
5528 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5529 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5530 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5531 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5532
5533 Here is some background info to help
5534 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5535 the str9:
5536 @enumerate
5537 @item
5538 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5539 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5540 @item
5541 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5542 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5543 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5544 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5545 @end enumerate
5546
5547 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5548 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5549 configured for flash bank 0.
5550 @example
5551 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5552 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5553 jtag_reset 0 1
5554 # turn off target polling
5555 poll off
5556 # disable str9 core
5557 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5558 # read option bytes
5559 str9xpec options_read 0
5560 # re-enable str9 core
5561 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5562 poll on
5563 reset halt
5564 @end example
5565 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5566 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5567 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5568 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5569
5570 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5571
5572 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5573 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5574 @end deffn
5575
5576 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5577 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5578 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5579 @end deffn
5580
5581 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5582 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5583 erase the device.
5584 @end deffn
5585
5586 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5587 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5588 @end deffn
5589
5590 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5591 Configure str9 boot bank.
5592 @end deffn
5593
5594 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5595 Configure str9 lvd source.
5596 @end deffn
5597
5598 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5599 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5600 @end deffn
5601
5602 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5603 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5604 @end deffn
5605
5606 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5607 Read str9 option bytes.
5608 @end deffn
5609
5610 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5611 Write str9 option bytes.
5612 @end deffn
5613
5614 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5615 unlock str9 device.
5616 @end deffn
5617
5618 @end deffn
5619
5620 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5621 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5622 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5623 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5624
5625 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5626
5627 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5628 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5632 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5633 @end deffn
5634
5635 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5636 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5637 the flash clock.
5638 @end deffn
5639 @end deffn
5640
5641 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5642 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5643 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5644 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5645 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5646 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5647 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5648
5649 @example
5650 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5651 @end example
5652 @end deffn
5653
5654 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5655 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5656 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5657 and SWD interface.
5658 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5659 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5660
5661 @example
5662 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5663 @end example
5664
5665 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5666
5667 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5668 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5669 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5670 @end deffn
5671
5672 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5673 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5674 @end deffn
5675 @end deffn
5676
5677 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5678 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5679 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5680
5681 @example
5682 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5683 @end example
5684
5685 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5686
5687 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5688 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5689 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5690 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5691 code.
5692 @end deffn
5693
5694 @end deffn
5695
5696 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5697 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5698 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5699 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5700
5701 @example
5702 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5703 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5704 @end example
5705
5706 @itemize @bullet
5707 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5708 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5709 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5710 @end itemize
5711
5712 Example usage:
5713 @example
5714 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5715 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5716 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5717 @} else @{
5718 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5719 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5720 @}
5721 @end example
5722 @end deffn
5723
5724 @section NAND Flash Commands
5725 @cindex NAND
5726
5727 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5728 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5729 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5730
5731 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5732 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5733 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5734 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5735 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5736 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5737
5738 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5739 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5740 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5741 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5742 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5743 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5744 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5745 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5746 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5747 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5748
5749 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5750 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5751 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5752 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5753 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5754 every 512 bytes of data.
5755
5756 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5757 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5758 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5759 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5760 ECC mode is used.
5761
5762 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5763 @enumerate
5764 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5765 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5766 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5767 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5768 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5769 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5770 to access that device.
5771 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5772 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5773 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5774 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5775 de-brick a board.
5776 @end enumerate
5777
5778 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5779 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5780 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5781 are only 32 bits wide.
5782 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5783 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5784 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5785 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5786
5787 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5788 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
5789 @cindex NAND configuration
5790
5791 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5792 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5793 OpenOCD has initialized.
5794
5795 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5796 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5797 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5798 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5799 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5800 they were a single (larger) device.
5801 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5802 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5803
5804 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5805 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5806 configuration files, not interactively.
5807
5808 @itemize @bullet
5809 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5810 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5811 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5812 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5813 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5814 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5815 commands to the NAND controller.
5816 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5817 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5818 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5819 for more information.
5820 @end itemize
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn Command {nand list}
5824 Prints a summary of each device declared
5825 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5826 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5827 @example
5828 > nand list
5829 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5830 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5831 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5832 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5833 >
5834 @end example
5835 @end deffn
5836
5837 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5838 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5839 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5840 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5841 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5842 it with most other NAND commands.
5843 @end deffn
5844
5845 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5846
5847 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5848 @cindex NAND reading
5849 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5850 starting at the specified offset.
5851 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5852
5853 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5854 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5855
5856 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
5857 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
5858 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
5859
5860 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
5861 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
5862 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
5863 method which handled that error correction.
5864
5865 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
5866 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
5867 @itemize @bullet
5868 @item no oob_* parameter
5869 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
5870 @item @code{oob_raw}
5871 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
5872 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
5873 spare areas associated with each data page.
5874 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
5875 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
5876 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
5877 @item @code{oob_only}
5878 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
5879 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
5880 spare areas associated with each data page.
5881 @end itemize
5882 @end deffn
5883
5884 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
5885 @cindex NAND erasing
5886 @cindex NAND programming
5887 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
5888 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
5889 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5890 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5891 If those parameters are not specified,
5892 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
5893 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5894
5895 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
5896 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
5897 block marker.
5898 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
5899 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
5900 @end deffn
5901
5902 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
5903 @cindex NAND writing
5904 @cindex NAND programming
5905 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
5906 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
5907 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
5908 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5909
5910 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5911 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5912
5913 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5914 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
5915 past the end of the device.
5916 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
5917 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
5918 if that's being written.)
5919
5920 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
5921 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
5922 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
5923
5924 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
5925 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
5926 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
5927 @itemize @bullet
5928 @item no oob_* parameter
5929 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5930 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
5931 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5932 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
5933 with hardware-computed ECC data.
5934 @item @code{oob_only}
5935 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
5936 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
5937 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
5938 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
5939 @item @code{oob_raw}
5940 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
5941 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
5942 un-altered OOB.
5943 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5944 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
5945 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
5946 @item @code{oob_softecc}
5947 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5948 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
5949 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
5950 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
5951 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
5952 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
5953 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5954 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
5955 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
5956 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
5957 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
5958 @end itemize
5959 @end deffn
5960
5961 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
5962 @cindex NAND verification
5963 @cindex NAND programming
5964 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
5965 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
5966 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5967
5968 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5969 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5970
5971 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5972 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
5973 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
5974 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
5975 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
5976
5977 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
5978 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
5979 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
5980
5981 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
5982 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
5983 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
5984 be removed in a future release.
5985 @end deffn
5986
5987 @subsection Other NAND commands
5988 @cindex NAND other commands
5989
5990 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
5991 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
5992 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
5993 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
5994 continues for @var{length} bytes.
5995 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5996 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5997 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5998
5999 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6000 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6001 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6002 @end deffn
6003
6004 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6005 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6006 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6007 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6008 status for each block.
6009 @end deffn
6010
6011 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6012 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6013 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6014
6015 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6016 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6017 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6018 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6019 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6020
6021 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6022 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6023 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6024 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6025 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6026 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6027 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6028 @end deffn
6029
6030 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6031 @subsection NAND Driver List
6032 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6033 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6034 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6035
6036 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6037 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6038 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6039 address of the ECC controller.
6040 @example
6041 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6042 @end example
6043 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6044 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6045 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6046 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6047 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6048 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6049 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6050 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6051 @end deffn
6052 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6053 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6054 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6055 @end deffn
6056
6057 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6058 properly configured for input or output.
6059 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6060 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6061 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6062 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6063 @end deffn
6064 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6065 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6066 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6067 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6068 @end deffn
6069 @end deffn
6070
6071 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6072 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6073 chips from Texas Instruments.
6074 It takes three extra parameters:
6075 address of the NAND chip;
6076 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6077 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6078 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6079 @example
6080 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6081 @end example
6082 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6083 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6084 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6085 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6086 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6087 @end deffn
6088
6089 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6090 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6091 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6092 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6093 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6094 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6095 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6096 @end deffn
6097
6098 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6099 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6100 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6101 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6102 @end deffn
6103 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6104
6105 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6106 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6107 should work for this chip aswell.
6108 @end deffn
6109
6110 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6111 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6112 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6113 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6114 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6115 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6116 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6117 @example
6118 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6119 @end example
6120 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6121 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6122 without parameter query status.
6123 @end deffn
6124 @end deffn
6125
6126 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6127 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6128 parameter: the address of the controller.
6129 @example
6130 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6131 @end example
6132 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6133 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6134 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6135 change any behavior.
6136 @end deffn
6137
6138 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6139 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6140 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6141 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6142 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6143 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6144 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6145 specialized commands.
6146 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6147 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6148 change any behavior.
6149 @end deffn
6150
6151 @section mFlash
6152
6153 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6154 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6155
6156 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6157 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6158 address @var{base}.
6159 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6160 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6161
6162 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6163
6164 @example
6165 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6166 @end example
6167
6168 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6169
6170 @example
6171 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6172 @end example
6173 @end deffn
6174
6175 @subsection mFlash commands
6176 @cindex mFlash commands
6177
6178 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6179 Configure mflash PLL.
6180 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6181 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6182 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6183 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6187 Configure bootable option.
6188 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6189 (4kB) for boot.
6190 @end deffn
6191
6192 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6193 Configure storage information.
6194 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6195 written.
6196 @end deffn
6197
6198 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6199 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6200 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6201 @end deffn
6202
6203 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6204 Probe mflash.
6205 @end deffn
6206
6207 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6208 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6209 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @node Flash Programming
6213 @chapter Flash Programming
6214
6215 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6216 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6217 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6218
6219 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6220 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6221
6222 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6223 @enumerate
6224 @item 'init' is executed.
6225 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6226 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6227 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6228 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6229 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6230 @end enumerate
6231
6232 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6233
6234 @example
6235 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6236 # are optional parameters
6237 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6238 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6239
6240 # binary files need the flash address passing
6241 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6242 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6243 @end example
6244
6245 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6246 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6247 @cindex PLD
6248 @cindex FPGA
6249
6250 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6251 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6252 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6253 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6254 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6255 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6256 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6257
6258 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6259
6260 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6261 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6262 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6263
6264 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6265 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6266
6267 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6268 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6269 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6270 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6271 behavior.
6272 @end deffn
6273
6274 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6275 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6276 @end deffn
6277
6278 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6279 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6280 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6281 @end deffn
6282
6283 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6284
6285 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6286 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6287 that particular type of PLD.
6288
6289 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6290 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6291 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6292
6293 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6294 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6295 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6296
6297 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6298 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6299 for FPGA @var{num}.
6300 @end deffn
6301 @end deffn
6302
6303 @node General Commands
6304 @chapter General Commands
6305 @cindex commands
6306
6307 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6308 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6309 commands are documented elsewhere.
6310
6311 Intent:
6312 @itemize @bullet
6313 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6314 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6315 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6316 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6317
6318 @item @b{From the human}
6319 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6320 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6321
6322 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6323 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6324 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6325
6326 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6327 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6328 port is 5555.
6329 @end itemize
6330
6331
6332 @section Daemon Commands
6333
6334 @deffn {Command} exit
6335 Exits the current telnet session.
6336 @end deffn
6337
6338 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6339 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6340 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6341 Not every command provides helptext.
6342
6343 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6344 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6345 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6346 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6347 @end deffn
6348
6349 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6350 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6351 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6352 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6353 Useful in connection with script files
6354 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6355 @end deffn
6356
6357 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6358 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6359 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6360 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6361 @end deffn
6362
6363 @anchor{debuglevel}
6364 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6365 @cindex message level
6366 Display debug level.
6367 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6368 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6369 Level 0 is error messages only;
6370 level 1 adds warnings;
6371 level 2 adds informational messages;
6372 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6373 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6374 the command line along with the location of that log
6375 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6376 @xref{Running}.
6377 @end deffn
6378
6379 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6380 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6381 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6382 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6383 @example
6384 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6385 @end example
6386 @end deffn
6387
6388 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6389 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6390 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6391 @end deffn
6392
6393 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6394 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6398 @section Target State handling
6399 @cindex reset
6400 @cindex halt
6401 @cindex target initialization
6402
6403 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6404 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6405 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6406 a current target which is used to perform the
6407 various operations. The current target may be changed
6408 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6409 target which should become current.
6410
6411 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6412 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6413 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6414 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6415 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6416
6417 @emph{With no arguments}:
6418 list all available registers for the current target,
6419 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6420 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6421 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6422 are flagged as such.
6423
6424 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6425 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6426 bypassing any internal cache.
6427
6428 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6429 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6430 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6431 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6432 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6433 relevant module will flush such values.
6434
6435 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6436 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6437
6438 @example
6439 > reg
6440 ===== ARM registers
6441 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6442 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6443 (2) r2 (/32)
6444 ...
6445 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6446 >
6447 @end example
6448 @end deffn
6449
6450 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6451 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6452 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6453 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6454 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6455 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6456 (and enter debug mode).
6457 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6458
6459 @quotation Warning
6460 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6461 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6462 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6463 power mode by gating the core clock;
6464 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6465
6466 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6467 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6468 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6469 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6470 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6471 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6472
6473 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6474 work with a JTAG debugger.
6475 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6476 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6477 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6478 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6479 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6480 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6481 @end quotation
6482
6483 @end deffn
6484
6485 @deffn Command resume [address]
6486 Resume the target at its current code position,
6487 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6488 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6489 @end deffn
6490
6491 @deffn Command step [address]
6492 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6493 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @anchor{resetcommand}
6497 @deffn Command reset
6498 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6499 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6500 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6501 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6502 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6503 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6504
6505 The optional parameter specifies what should
6506 happen after the reset.
6507 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6508 The other options will not work on all systems.
6509 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6510
6511 @itemize @minus
6512 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6513 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6514 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6515 @end itemize
6516 @end deffn
6517
6518 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6519 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6520 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6521 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6522 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6523 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6524 state.
6525 @end deffn
6526
6527 @section I/O Utilities
6528
6529 These commands are available when
6530 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6531 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6532 notably the ZY1000.
6533 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6534
6535 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6536
6537 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6538 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6539 the text file @file{filename}.
6540 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6541 The last string is followed by a newline.
6542 @end deffn
6543
6544 @deffn Command cat filename
6545 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6546 @end deffn
6547
6548 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6549 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6550 into @file{dest_filename}.
6551 @end deffn
6552
6553 @deffn Command ip
6554 @emph{No description provided.}
6555 @end deffn
6556
6557 @deffn Command ls
6558 @emph{No description provided.}
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @deffn Command mac
6562 @emph{No description provided.}
6563 @end deffn
6564
6565 @deffn Command meminfo
6566 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6567 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6568 @end deffn
6569
6570 @deffn Command peek
6571 @emph{No description provided.}
6572 @end deffn
6573
6574 @deffn Command poke
6575 @emph{No description provided.}
6576 @end deffn
6577
6578 @deffn Command rm filename
6579 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6580 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @deffn Command trunc filename
6584 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6585 @end deffn
6586
6587 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6588 @section Memory access commands
6589 @cindex memory access
6590
6591 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6592 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6593 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6594 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6595
6596 @enumerate
6597 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6598 to change the current target.
6599 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6600 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6601 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6602 @end enumerate
6603
6604 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6605 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6606 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6607 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6608 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6609 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6610 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6611 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6612 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6613 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6614 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6615 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6616 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6620 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6621 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6622 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6623 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6624 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6625 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6626 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6627 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6628 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @anchor{imageaccess}
6632 @section Image loading commands
6633 @cindex image loading
6634 @cindex image dumping
6635
6636 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6637 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6638 binary file named @var{filename}.
6639 @end deffn
6640
6641 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6642 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6643 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6644 @end deffn
6645
6646 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6647 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6648 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6649 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6650 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6651 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6652 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6653 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6654 separately.
6655 @end deffn
6656
6657 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6658 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6659 The file format may optionally be specified
6660 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6661 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6662 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6663 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6664 @example
6665 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6666 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6667 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6668 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6669 $address $length
6670 @}
6671 @end example
6672 @end deffn
6673
6674 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6675 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6676 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6677 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6678 The file format may optionally be specified
6679 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6680 @end deffn
6681
6682 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6683 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6684 The file format may optionally be specified
6685 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6686 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689
6690 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6691 @cindex breakpoint
6692 @cindex watchpoint
6693
6694 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6695 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6696 watchpoints.
6697 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6698
6699 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6700 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6701 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6702 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6703 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6704 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6705
6706 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6707 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6708 @end deffn
6709
6710 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6711 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6712 @end deffn
6713
6714 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6715 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6719 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6720 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6721 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6722 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6723 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6724 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6725 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6726 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6727 @end deffn
6728
6729 @section Misc Commands
6730
6731 @cindex profiling
6732 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6733 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6734 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6735 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6736 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6737 limit the address range.
6738 @end deffn
6739
6740 @deffn Command {version}
6741 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6742 @end deffn
6743
6744 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6745 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6746 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6747 @end deffn
6748
6749 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6750 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6751 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6752 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6753
6754 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6755 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6756 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6757 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6758
6759 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6760 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6761 @cindex tracing
6762 @cindex ETM
6763 @cindex ETB
6764
6765 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6766 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6767 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6768
6769 @itemize
6770 @item
6771 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6772 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6773 supports such an interface.
6774 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6775 and trace port support.)
6776 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6777 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6778 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6779 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6780 in the board-specific configuration file.
6781 @item
6782 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6783 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6784 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6785 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6786 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6787 @end itemize
6788
6789 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6790
6791 @quotation Issues
6792 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6793 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6794
6795 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6796 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6797 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6798 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6799 dummy trace port driver}.
6800
6801 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6802 as well as tracing only during specific states
6803 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6804
6805 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6806 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6807 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6808 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6809 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6810
6811 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6812 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6813 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6814 this original style of JTAG access.
6815 @end quotation
6816
6817 @subsection ETM Configuration
6818 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6819
6820 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6821 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6822 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6823
6824 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6825 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6826 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6827 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6828 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6829 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6830 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6831 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6832 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6833
6834 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6835 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6836 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6837
6838 @quotation Warning
6839 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6840 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6841 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6842 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6843 @end quotation
6844
6845 @quotation Note
6846 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6847 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6848 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6849 what CPU activities are traced.
6850 @end quotation
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn Command {etm info}
6854 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6855 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6856 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6857 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6858 @end deffn
6859
6860 @deffn Command {etm status}
6861 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6862 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6863 Did trace data overflow?
6864 Was it triggered?
6865 @end deffn
6866
6867 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6868 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6869 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6870 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6871 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6872
6873 @itemize
6874 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6875 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6876 The value is one of
6877 @option{none} (save nothing),
6878 @option{data} (save data),
6879 @option{address} (save addresses),
6880 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6881 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6882 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6883 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6884 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6885 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6886 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6887 trace stream without an image of the code.
6888 @end itemize
6889 @end deffn
6890
6891 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6892 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
6893 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
6894 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
6895 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
6896
6897 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
6898 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
6899 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
6900 @end deffn
6901
6902 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
6903
6904 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
6905 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
6906 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
6907
6908 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
6909 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
6910 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
6911 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
6912 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
6913 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
6914 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
6915
6916 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
6917
6918 @itemize
6919 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
6920 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
6921 for instruction access within that function's body.
6922 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
6923 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
6924 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
6925 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
6926 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
6927 combining one of the above models with a counter.
6928 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
6929 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
6930 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
6931 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
6932 @item @emph{... more}
6933 @end itemize
6934
6935 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
6936 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
6937
6938 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
6939 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
6940 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
6941 @end deffn
6942
6943 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
6944 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
6945 @end deffn
6946
6947 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
6948 Opens an image file.
6949 @end deffn
6950
6951 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
6952 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
6953 @end deffn
6954
6955 @deffn Command {etm start}
6956 Starts trace data collection.
6957 @end deffn
6958
6959 @deffn Command {etm stop}
6960 Stops trace data collection.
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
6964 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
6965
6966 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
6967
6968 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
6969 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6970 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
6971 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
6972 any trace data collection.}
6973 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
6974 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
6975 @end deffn
6976 @end deffn
6977
6978 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
6979 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
6980 to use on-chip ETB memory.
6981 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
6982 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
6983 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
6984 @end deffn
6985 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
6986 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
6987 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
6988 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
6989 trace trigger becomes active.
6990
6991 @itemize
6992 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
6993 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
6994 afterwards.
6995 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
6996 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
6997 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
6998 what caused that event to happen.
6999 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7000 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7001 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7002 how the event caused trouble.
7003 @end itemize
7004 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7010 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7011 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7012 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7013 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7014
7015 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7016 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7017
7018 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7019 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7020 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7024 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7025 @end deffn
7026
7027 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7028 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7029 @end deffn
7030 @end deffn
7031
7032
7033 @section Generic ARM
7034 @cindex ARM
7035
7036 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7037 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7038 commands that may be available.
7039
7040 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7041 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7042 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7043 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7044 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7045 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7046 @end deffn
7047
7048 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7049 @cindex disassemble
7050 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7051 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7052 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7053 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7054 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7055 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7056 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7057
7058 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7059 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7060 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7061 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7062 with a handful of exceptions.
7063 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7064 @end deffn
7065
7066 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7067 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7068 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7069 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7070 and using the MCR instruction.
7071 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7072 an ARM register.)
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7076 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7077 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7078 and the MRC instruction.
7079 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7080 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7081 an ARM register.)
7082 @end deffn
7083
7084 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7085 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7086 core mode if necessary.
7087 @end deffn
7088
7089 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7090 @cindex ARM semihosting
7091 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7092
7093 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7094 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7095 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7096 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7097 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7098 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7099 @end deffn
7100
7101 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7102 @cindex ARMv4
7103 @cindex ARMv5
7104
7105 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7106 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7107 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7108 variant.
7109
7110 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7111 @cindex ARM7
7112 @cindex ARM9
7113
7114 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7115 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7116 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7117 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7118
7119 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7120 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7121 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7122 instead of breakpoints.
7123 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7124
7125 This should be
7126 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7127 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7128 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7132 @cindex DCC
7133 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7134 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7135 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7136
7137 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7138 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7139 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7140 @end deffn
7141
7142 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7143 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7144 that don't check completion of the operation.
7145 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7146
7147 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7148 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7149 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7150 @end deffn
7151
7152 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7153 @cindex ARM720T
7154
7155 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7156 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7157 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7158 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7159
7160 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7161 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7162 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7163
7164 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7165 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7166 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7167 @end deffn
7168
7169 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7170 @cindex ARM9
7171
7172 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7173 integer processors.
7174 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7175
7176 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7177 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7178 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7179 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7180
7181 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7182 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7183 @cindex vector_catch
7184 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7185 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7186 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7187 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7188 to those hardware vectors.
7189
7190 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7191 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7192 vector catch hardware to intercept
7193 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7194 @option{none} of them,
7195 or a list with one or more of the following:
7196 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7197 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7201 @cindex ARM920T
7202
7203 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7204 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7205 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7206 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7207 and ARM9 commands.
7208
7209 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7210 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7211 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7215 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7216 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7217 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7218 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7219 (Not all registers can be written.)
7220 @end deffn
7221
7222 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7223 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7224 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7225
7226 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7227 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7228 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7229 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7230 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7231 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7235 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7236 @end deffn
7237
7238 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7239 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7243 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7244
7245 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7246 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7247 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7248 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7249 and ARM9 commands.
7250
7251 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7252 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7253
7254 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7255 Print information about the caches found.
7256 @end deffn
7257
7258 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7259 @cindex ARM966E
7260
7261 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7262 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7263 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7264 and ARM9 commands.
7265
7266 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7267 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7268 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7269 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7270 ARM966E-S TRM.
7271 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7272 as required for BIST support.
7273 @end deffn
7274
7275 @subsection XScale specific commands
7276 @cindex XScale
7277
7278 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7279
7280 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7281 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7282 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7283 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7284 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7285 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7286 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7287
7288 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7289 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7290 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7291 the mini-IC.
7292
7293 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7294 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7295 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7296 code layout in memory:
7297 @example
7298 _vectors:
7299 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7300 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7301 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7302 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7303 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7304 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7305 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7306 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7307 .org 0x100
7308 .long real_reset_vector
7309 .long real_ui_handler
7310 .long real_swi_handler
7311 .long real_pf_abort
7312 .long real_data_abort
7313 .long 0 /* unused */
7314 .long real_irq_handler
7315 .long real_fiq_handler
7316 @end example
7317
7318 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7319 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7320 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7321 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7322 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7323 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7324 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7325 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7326 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7327 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7328 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7329 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7330 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7331 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7332 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7333 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7334 software.
7335
7336 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7337 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7338 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7339 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7340
7341 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7342 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7343 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7344 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7345 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7346 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7347 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7348 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7349 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7350
7351 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7352 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7353
7354 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7355 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7359 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7360 @end deffn
7361
7362 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7363 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7367 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7368 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7369 @end deffn
7370
7371 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7372 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7373 @end deffn
7374
7375 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7376 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7377 @end deffn
7378
7379 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7380 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7381 @end deffn
7382
7383 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7384 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7385 @end deffn
7386
7387 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7388 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7389 @end deffn
7390
7391 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7392 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7393 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7394 and modifying how it is emptied.
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7398 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7399 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7400 The image @var{type} may be one of
7401 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7402 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7403 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7404 @end deffn
7405
7406 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7407 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7408 @cindex vector_catch
7409 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7410 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7411
7412 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7413 @example
7414 0x01 Trap Reset
7415 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7416 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7417 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7418 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7419 0x20 reserved
7420 0x40 Trap IRQ
7421 0x80 Trap FIQ
7422 @end example
7423 @end deffn
7424
7425 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7426 @cindex vector_table
7427
7428 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7429 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7430 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7431 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7432 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7433
7434 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7435
7436 @end deffn
7437
7438 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7439 @cindex ARMv6
7440
7441 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7442 @cindex ARM11
7443
7444 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7445 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7446 which is enabled by default.
7447 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7448 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7449 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7450 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7451 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7452 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7453 @end deffn
7454
7455 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7456 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7457 which is enabled by default.
7458 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7459 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7460 @end deffn
7461
7462 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7463 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7464 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7465 they are disabled by default.
7466 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7467 @end deffn
7468
7469 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7470 @cindex vector_catch
7471 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7472 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7473 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7474
7475 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7476 for certain hardware events.
7477 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7478 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7479 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7480 @end deffn
7481
7482 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7483 @cindex ARMv7
7484
7485 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7486 @cindex Debug Access Port
7487 @cindex DAP
7488 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7489 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7490 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7491
7492 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7493 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7494 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7495 @end deffn
7496
7497 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7498 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7499 @end deffn
7500
7501 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7502 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7503 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7504 @end deffn
7505
7506 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7507 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7508 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7509 @end deffn
7510
7511 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7512 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7513 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7514 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7515 @end deffn
7516
7517 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7518 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7519 Defaulting to 0.
7520 @end deffn
7521
7522 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7523 @cindex tracing
7524 @cindex SWO
7525 @cindex SWV
7526 @cindex TPIU
7527 @cindex ITM
7528 @cindex ETM
7529
7530 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal @var{filename}}) @
7531 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7532 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7533
7534 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7535 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7536 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7537 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7538
7539 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7540 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7541 debugger adapter features.
7542
7543 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7544 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7545
7546 Command options:
7547 @itemize @minus
7548 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7549 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7550 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7551 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7552 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7553 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7554 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7555 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7556 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7557 coding;
7558 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7559 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7560 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7561 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7562 data is to be output via SWO;
7563 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7564 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7565 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7566 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7567 rate automatically.
7568 @end itemize
7569
7570 Example usage:
7571 @enumerate
7572 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7573 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7574 enough to:
7575 @example
7576 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7577 ...
7578 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7579 ...
7580 @end example
7581 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7582 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7583 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7584 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7585 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7586 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7587 @example
7588 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7589 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7590 @end example
7591 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7592 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7593 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7594 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7595 @example
7596 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7597 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7598 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7599 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7600 @end example
7601 @end enumerate
7602 @end deffn
7603
7604 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7605 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7606 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7607 @end deffn
7608
7609 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7610 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7611 @end deffn
7612
7613 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7614 @cindex Cortex-M
7615
7616 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7617 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7618
7619 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7620 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7621 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7622 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7623 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7624 the step command leaves with the core running.
7625
7626 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7627 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7628 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7629
7630 Default is @option{auto}.
7631 @end deffn
7632
7633 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7634 @cindex vector_catch
7635 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7636 for certain hardware events.
7637
7638 Parameters request interception of
7639 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7640 @option{none} of them,
7641 or one or more of the following:
7642 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7643 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7644 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7645 @option{irq_err},
7646 @option{state_err},
7647 @option{chk_err}, or
7648 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7649 @option{reset}.
7650 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7651 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7652 are mapped to HardFault.
7653 UsageFault checks for
7654 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7655 must also be explicitly enabled.
7656
7657 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7658 @end deffn
7659
7660 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7661 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7662 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7663 @itemize @minus
7664 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7665 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7666 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7667 @end itemize
7668 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7669 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7670 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7671 the peripherals.
7672 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675 @section Intel Architecture
7676
7677 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7678 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7679 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7680 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7681 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7682 @itemize
7683 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7684 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7685 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7686 @end itemize
7687
7688 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7689 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7690 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7691
7692 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7693 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7694 @end deffn
7695
7696 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7697 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7698 @end deffn
7699
7700 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7701 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7702 @end deffn
7703
7704 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7705 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7706 @end deffn
7707
7708 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7709 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7710 @end deffn
7711
7712 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7713 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7714 @end deffn
7715
7716 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7717
7718 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7719 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7720
7721 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7722 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7723 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7724 @end deffn
7725 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7726 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7727
7728 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7729
7730 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7731 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7732 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7733 @end deffn
7734
7735 @subsection Registers commands
7736 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7737 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7738 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7739
7740 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7741
7742 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7743 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7744 and "timer" groups.
7745
7746 @emph{example:}
7747 @example
7748 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7749 @end example
7750
7751
7752 @end deffn
7753 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7754 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7755
7756 @emph{group} can be "system",
7757 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7758 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7759 @end deffn
7760
7761 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7762 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7763 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7764 @cindex tracing
7765 @cindex libdcc
7766 @cindex DCC
7767 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7768 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7769 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7770 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7771
7772 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7773 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7774 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7775 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7776 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7777 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7778
7779 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7780 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7781 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7782 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7783 The target being debugged may
7784 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7785 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7786 each supported by a command:
7787
7788 @itemize
7789 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7790 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7791 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7792 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7793
7794 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7795 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7796 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7797
7798 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7799 and then displayed at any time.
7800 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7801
7802 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7803 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7804 @end itemize
7805
7806 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7807 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7808 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7809 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7810 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7811 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7812 does the same thing.
7813
7814 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7815 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7816 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7817 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7818 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7819
7820 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7821 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7822 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7823 @end deffn
7824
7825 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7826 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7827 in the order they triggered.
7828 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7829 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7830 history records.
7831 @end deffn
7832
7833 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7834 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7835 they have been triggered.
7836 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7837 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7838 and associates it with that identifier.
7839
7840 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7841 are not related except by this command.
7842 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7843 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7844 @end deffn
7845
7846
7847 @node JTAG Commands
7848 @chapter JTAG Commands
7849 @cindex JTAG Commands
7850 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7851 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7852 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7853 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7854 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7855
7856 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7857 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7858
7859 @itemize @bullet
7860 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7861 devices such as a CPUs.
7862 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7863 standard state machine (in parallel)
7864 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7865 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7866 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7867 while the reading previous ones.
7868 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7869 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7870 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7871 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7872 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7873 registers.
7874 @end itemize
7875
7876 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7877
7878 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7879 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7880 the order of TAP state transitions.
7881 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7882 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7883 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7884 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7885 these commands are not available.
7886
7887 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7888 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7889 that specify the entire register.
7890 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
7891 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
7892 The return value holds the original value of each
7893 of those fields.
7894
7895 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
7896 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
7897 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
7898 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
7899 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
7900
7901 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
7902 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
7903
7904 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7905 in that state.
7906 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
7907 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7908 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7909
7910 @quotation Warning
7911 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
7912 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
7913 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
7914 data registers, which may have different lengths.
7915 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
7916 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
7917 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
7918 (by connecting a different scan chain).
7919 @end quotation
7920 @end deffn
7921
7922 @deffn Command {flush_count}
7923 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
7924 This may be used for performance tuning.
7925
7926 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
7927 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
7928 not change with the amount of data which is written.
7929 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
7930 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
7931 instead of batching them into larger operations.
7932 @end deffn
7933
7934 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7935 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
7936 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
7937 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
7938 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
7939 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
7940
7941 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7942 in that state.
7943 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
7944 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7945 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7946
7947 @quotation Note
7948 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
7949 register values, unlike data register values.
7950 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
7951 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
7952 @end quotation
7953 @end deffn
7954
7955 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
7956 Set values of reset signals.
7957 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
7958 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
7959 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
7960 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7961 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
7962 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7963 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7964
7965 Note that TRST is specially handled.
7966 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7967 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7968 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7969 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7970 instead of the TRST signal.
7971 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7972 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7973 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7974 with handlers for that event.
7975 @end deffn
7976
7977 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
7978 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
7979 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
7980 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
7981 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
7982 Then, in a series of single state transitions
7983 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
7984 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
7985 The final state must also be stable.
7986 @end deffn
7987
7988 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
7989 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
7990 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
7991 Instructions often need some time
7992 to execute before they take effect.
7993 @end deffn
7994
7995 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
7996 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
7997
7998 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7999 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8000 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8001 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8002 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8003 @end deffn
8004
8005 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8006 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8007 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8008 must also be enabled.
8009 Default is enabled.
8010 @end deffn
8011
8012 @section TAP state names
8013 @cindex TAP state names
8014
8015 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8016 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8017 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8018 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8019
8020 @itemize @bullet
8021 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8022 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8023 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8024 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8025 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8026 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8027 through the data register
8028 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8029 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8030 for update or more shifting
8031 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8032 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8033 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8034 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8035 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8036 through the instruction register
8037 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8038 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8039 for update or more shifting
8040 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8041 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8042 @end itemize
8043
8044 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8045 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8046 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8047 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8048
8049 @itemize @bullet
8050 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8051 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8052 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8053 may not be as expected.
8054 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8055 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8056 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8057 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8058 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8059 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8060 @end itemize
8061
8062 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8063 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8064
8065 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8066 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8067 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8068 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8069
8070 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8071 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8072 @cindex SVF
8073
8074 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8075 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8076 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8077 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8078
8079 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8080 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8081 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8082 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8083 each command is logged before it is executed.
8084 @end deffn
8085
8086 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8087 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8088 @cindex XSVF
8089
8090 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8091 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8092 Xilinx devices.
8093 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8094 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8095
8096 @quotation Important
8097 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8098 @end quotation
8099
8100 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8101 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8102 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8103 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8104 that TAP.
8105 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8106 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8107 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8108 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8109 @end deffn
8110
8111 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8112 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8113 after building the software.
8114 You may find them useful:
8115
8116 @itemize
8117 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8118 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8119 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8120 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8121 @end itemize
8122
8123 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8124 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8125 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8126 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8127 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8128 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8129 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8130
8131
8132 @node Utility Commands
8133 @chapter Utility Commands
8134 @cindex Utility Commands
8135
8136 @section RAM testing
8137 @cindex RAM testing
8138
8139 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8140 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8141 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8142 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8143 hardware problems.
8144
8145 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8146 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8147 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8148 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8149
8150 Load the memory testing functions with
8151
8152 @example
8153 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8154 @end example
8155
8156 to get access to the following facilities:
8157
8158 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8159 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8160 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8161 @end deffn
8162
8163 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8164 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8165 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8166 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8167 @end deffn
8168
8169 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8170 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8171 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8172 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8173 @end deffn
8174
8175 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8176 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8177 @end deffn
8178
8179 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8180 @cindex Firmware recovery
8181
8182 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8183 devices recovery with JTAG.
8184
8185 For quickstart instructions run:
8186 @example
8187 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8188 @end example
8189
8190 @node TFTP
8191 @chapter TFTP
8192 @cindex TFTP
8193 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8194 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8195
8196 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8197 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8198 server (tftpd). For example,
8199
8200 @example
8201 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8202 @end example
8203
8204 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8205 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8206
8207 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8208 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8209 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8210 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8211
8212 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8213 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8214 @cindex GDB
8215 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8216 to debug remote targets.
8217 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8218
8219 @itemize
8220 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8221 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8222 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8223 as shown in this chapter.
8224 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8225 that also will probably need to be configured.
8226 @end itemize
8227
8228 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8229 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8230 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8231 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8232 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8233 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8234
8235 @section Connecting to GDB
8236 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8237 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8238 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8239 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8240 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8241
8242 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8243
8244 @enumerate
8245 @item
8246 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8247 @example
8248 target remote localhost:3333
8249 @end example
8250 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8251
8252 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8253 @example
8254 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8255 @end example
8256 @item
8257 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8258 @example
8259 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8260 @end example
8261 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8262 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8263 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8264 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8265 @end enumerate
8266
8267 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8268 GDB command line.
8269
8270 @section Sample GDB session startup
8271
8272 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8273 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8274 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8275 small ARM program.
8276 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8277 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8278
8279 @example
8280 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8281 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8282 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8283 ...
8284 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8285 ...
8286 (gdb) load
8287 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8288 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8289 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8290 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8291 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8292 (gdb) continue
8293 Continuing.
8294 ...
8295 @end example
8296
8297 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8298 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8299 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8300 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8301
8302 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8303
8304 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8305 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8306 packet size and the device's memory map.
8307 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8308 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8309 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8310
8311 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8312 You may need to set those up by hand.
8313 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8314 something like:
8315
8316 @example
8317 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8318 @end example
8319
8320 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8321
8322 @example
8323 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8324 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8325 @end example
8326
8327 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8328 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8329 do not have such restrictions.
8330
8331 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8332 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8333 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8334
8335 @example
8336 define hook-step
8337 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8338 end
8339 define hookpost-step
8340 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8341 end
8342 @end example
8343
8344 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8345 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8346 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8347 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8348
8349 @section Programming using GDB
8350 @cindex Programming using GDB
8351 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8352
8353 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8354 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8355 @example
8356 gdb_memory_map disable
8357 @end example
8358 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8359 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8360 working area.
8361
8362 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8363 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8364 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8365 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8366
8367 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8368 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8369
8370 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8371 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8372 @example
8373 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8374 @end example
8375
8376 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8377 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8378
8379 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8380 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8381 will be used.
8382
8383 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8384 script can be executed:
8385 @example
8386 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8387 @end example
8388
8389 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8390 can be used.
8391 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8392 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8393 @cindex SMP
8394 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8395 @itemize @bullet
8396 @item j - smp status request
8397 @item J - smp set request
8398 @end itemize
8399
8400 OpenOCD implements :
8401 @itemize @bullet
8402 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8403 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8404 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8405 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8406 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8407 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8408 @end itemize
8409
8410 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8411 @itemize @bullet
8412 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8413 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8414 @example
8415 set $_core 1
8416 #Jc01 packet is sent
8417 print $_core
8418 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8419 @end example
8420
8421 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8422 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8423
8424 @example
8425 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8426 define toggle0
8427 maint packet Jc0
8428 continue
8429 main packet Jc-1
8430 end
8431 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8432 define toggle1
8433 maint packet Jc1
8434 continue
8435 main packet Jc-1
8436 end
8437 @end example
8438 @end itemize
8439
8440 @section RTOS Support
8441 @cindex RTOS Support
8442 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8443
8444 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8445 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8446
8447 @* An example setup is below:
8448
8449 @example
8450 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8451 @end example
8452
8453 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8454
8455 Currently supported rtos's include:
8456 @itemize @bullet
8457 @item @option{eCos}
8458 @item @option{ThreadX}
8459 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8460 @item @option{linux}
8461 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8462 @item @option{embKernel}
8463 @item @option{mqx}
8464 @end itemize
8465
8466 @quotation Note
8467 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8468 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8469 @end quotation
8470
8471 @table @code
8472 @item eCos symbols
8473 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8474 @item ThreadX symbols
8475 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8476 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8477 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8478 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8479 @tex
8480 \begingroup
8481 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8482 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8483 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8484 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8485 \par
8486 \endgroup
8487 @end tex
8488 @item linux symbols
8489 init_task.
8490 @item ChibiOS symbols
8491 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8492 @item embKernel symbols
8493 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8494 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8495 @item mqx symbols
8496 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8497 @end table
8498
8499 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8500 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8501
8502 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8503 along with the project:
8504
8505 @table @code
8506 @item FreeRTOS
8507 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8508 @end table
8509
8510 @node Tcl Scripting API
8511 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8512 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8513 @cindex Tcl scripts
8514 @section API rules
8515
8516 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8517 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8518 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8519
8520 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8521 pair list and lists.
8522
8523 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8524 list.
8525
8526 @example
8527 > set foo(me) Duane
8528 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8529 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8530 > set foo(duck) Donald
8531 @end example
8532
8533 If one does this:
8534
8535 @example
8536 > set foo
8537 @end example
8538
8539 The result is:
8540
8541 @example
8542 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8543 @end example
8544
8545 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8546
8547 @verbatim
8548 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8549 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8550 }
8551 @end verbatim
8552
8553 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8554 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8555
8556 @section Internal low-level Commands
8557
8558 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8559 invoke directly.
8560
8561 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8562 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8563 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8564
8565 @itemize @bullet
8566 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8567
8568 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8569 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8570
8571 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8572 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8573
8574 Return information about the flash banks
8575
8576 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8577
8578 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8579 its execution. Example:
8580
8581 @example
8582 > capture "reset init"
8583 @end example
8584
8585 @end itemize
8586
8587 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8588 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8589 called "flash_banks".
8590
8591 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8592
8593 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8594 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8595 holds one of the following values:
8596
8597 @itemize @bullet
8598 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8599 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8600 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8601 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8602 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8603 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8604 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8605 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8606 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8607 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8608 @end itemize
8609
8610 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8611
8612 @quotation Note
8613 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8614 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8615 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8616 is jim, not real tcl).
8617 @end quotation
8618
8619 @section Tcl RPC server
8620 @cindex RPC
8621
8622 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8623 commands and receive the results.
8624
8625 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8626 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8627 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8628 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8629 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8630
8631 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8632 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8633 @command{capture} command.
8634
8635 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8636
8637 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8638 @cindex RPC Notifications
8639
8640 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8641 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8642
8643 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8644 in the following format.
8645
8646 @verbatim
8647 type target_event event [event-name]
8648 type target_state state [state-name]
8649 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8650 @end verbatim
8651
8652 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8653 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8654 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8655 Defaults to off.
8656
8657 @end deffn
8658
8659 @node FAQ
8660 @chapter FAQ
8661 @cindex faq
8662 @enumerate
8663 @anchor{faqrtck}
8664 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8665 @cindex RTCK
8666 @cindex adaptive clocking
8667 @*
8668
8669 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8670 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8671 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8672 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8673
8674 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8675 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8676 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8677 @enumerate
8678 @item
8679 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8680 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8681 @item
8682 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8683 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8684 @end enumerate
8685
8686 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8687 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8688 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8689 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8690 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8691 power).
8692
8693 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8694 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8695 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8696 ARM926 scenario).
8697 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8698 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8699 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8700
8701 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8702 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8703 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8704 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8705
8706 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8707
8708 In order to make use of this,
8709 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8710 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8711
8712 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8713 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8714 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8715 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8716 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8717
8718 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8719 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8720 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8721 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8722
8723 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8724 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8725 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8726 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8727 with a CPLD.
8728 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8729 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8730 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8731 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8732 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8733 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8734
8735 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8736
8737 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8738
8739 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8740 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8741 depending on the chips on your board.
8742 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8743 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8744 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8745
8746 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8747 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8748 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8749
8750 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8751 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8752 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8753 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8754
8755 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8756 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8757 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8758 this way.
8759
8760 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8761 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8762 clock rate.
8763 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8764 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8765 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8766
8767 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8768
8769 @example
8770 # Example: 1.234MHz
8771 adapter_khz 1234
8772 @end example
8773
8774
8775 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8776
8777 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8778 around Windows filenames.
8779
8780 @example
8781 > echo \a
8782
8783 > echo @{\a@}
8784 \a
8785 > echo "\a"
8786
8787 >
8788 @end example
8789
8790
8791 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8792
8793 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8794 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8795 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8796
8797 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8798 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8799 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8800
8801 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8802 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8803 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8804
8805 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8806
8807 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8808 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8809 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8810 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8811
8812 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8813 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8814 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8815
8816 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8817 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8818
8819 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8820 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8821 memory read caused data abort".
8822
8823 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8824 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8825 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8826 be done, feel free to add this here.
8827
8828 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8829 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8830 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8831 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8832 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8833 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8834 gracefully stops.
8835
8836 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8837 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8838 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8839
8840 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8841 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8842 bytes. Painful...
8843
8844
8845 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8846 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8847
8848 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8849 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8850 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8851 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8852 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8853 reset, everything else should work fine.
8854
8855 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8856 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8857 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8858 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8859
8860 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8861 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8862 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8863 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8864
8865 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8866
8867 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
8868 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
8869 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
8870 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8871
8872 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
8873 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
8874 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
8875 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
8876
8877 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
8878 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
8879 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8880
8881 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
8882 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
8883
8884 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
8885 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
8886 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
8887 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
8888 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
8889 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
8890 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
8891 clock frequency?
8892
8893 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
8894 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
8895 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
8896 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
8897 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
8898
8899 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
8900
8901 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
8902 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
8903 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
8904 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
8905 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
8906 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
8907 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
8908
8909 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
8910
8911 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
8912 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
8913 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
8914 up DRAM and loading it with code.
8915
8916 @anchor{faqtaporder}
8917 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
8918 particular order?
8919
8920 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
8921 the same order used by the hardware.
8922
8923 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
8924 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
8925 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
8926 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
8927 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
8928 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
8929
8930 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
8931 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
8932 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
8933 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
8934
8935 @itemize @bullet
8936 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
8937 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
8938 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
8939 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
8940 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
8941 @end itemize
8942
8943 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
8944
8945 @itemize @bullet
8946 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
8947 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
8948 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
8949 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
8950 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
8951 @end itemize
8952
8953
8954 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
8955 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
8956 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
8957
8958 TODO.
8959
8960 @end enumerate
8961
8962 @node Tcl Crash Course
8963 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
8964 @cindex Tcl
8965
8966 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
8967 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
8968 how the Tcl scripts work.
8969
8970 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
8971 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
8972 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
8973 OpenOCD.
8974
8975 @section Tcl Rule #1
8976 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
8977 @enumerate
8978 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
8979 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8980 @end enumerate
8981
8982 The Tcl equal is this:
8983
8984 @enumerate
8985 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
8986 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8987 @end enumerate
8988
8989 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
8990 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
8991
8992 @section Tcl Rule #1b
8993 There is a second pair of rules.
8994 @enumerate
8995 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
8996 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
8997 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
8998 in Tcl.
8999 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9000 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9001 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9002 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9003 @end enumerate
9004
9005 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9006 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9007 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9008 Everything is a string}
9009
9010 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9011 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9012 difference is subtle.
9013 @enumerate
9014 @item Parse Time
9015 @item Evaluation Time
9016 @end enumerate
9017
9018 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9019 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9020 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9021
9022 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9023 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9024 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9025 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9026
9027 @itemize @bullet
9028 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9029 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9030 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9031 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9032 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9033 @example
9034 # bash example
9035 X=`date`
9036 echo "The Date is: $X"
9037 # Tcl example
9038 set X [date]
9039 puts "The Date is: $X"
9040 @end example
9041 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9042 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9043 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9044 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9045 is a string}
9046 @example
9047 set x "Dinner"
9048 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9049 @end example
9050 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9051 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9052 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9053 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9054 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9055 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9056 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9057 @end itemize
9058
9059 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9060
9061 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9062
9063 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9064
9065 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9066 the normal way.
9067
9068 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9069 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9070 line is immedatly executed.
9071
9072 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9073 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9074
9075 @subsection Command Execution
9076
9077 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9078 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9079 control flow operators.
9080
9081 Commands are executed like this:
9082
9083 @enumerate
9084 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9085 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9086 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9087 @end enumerate
9088
9089 It sort of works like this:
9090 @example
9091 for(;;)@{
9092 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9093
9094 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9095
9096 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9097 @}
9098 @end example
9099
9100 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9101 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9102 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9103 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9104 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9105 ``LookupCommand()''
9106
9107 @subsection The FOR command
9108
9109 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9110 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9111 command just like any other command.
9112
9113 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9114 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9115 are:
9116
9117 @enumerate 0
9118 @item The ascii text 'for'
9119 @item The start text
9120 @item The test expression
9121 @item The next text
9122 @item The body text
9123 @end enumerate
9124
9125 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9126 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9127 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9128 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9129
9130 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9131 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9132
9133 @example
9134 int
9135 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9136 int *argc,
9137 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9138 @end example
9139
9140 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9141 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9142 still operates in the same basic way.
9143
9144 @subsection FOR command implementation
9145
9146 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9147 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9148
9149 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9150
9151 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9152
9153 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9154 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9155 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9156
9157 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9158 expression and returns a value.
9159
9160 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9161 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9162 @example
9163 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9164
9165 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9166
9167 int
9168 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9169 int argc,
9170 char **argv )
9171 @{
9172 if( argc != 5 )@{
9173 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9174 return ERROR;
9175 @}
9176
9177 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9178
9179 // Execute the start statement.
9180 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9181
9182 // Top of loop test
9183 for(;;)@{
9184 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9185 if( i == 0 )
9186 break;
9187
9188 // Execute the body
9189 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9190
9191 // Execute the LOOP part
9192 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9193 @}
9194
9195 // Return no error
9196 SetResult( interp, "" );
9197 return SUCCESS;
9198 @}
9199 @end example
9200
9201 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9202 in the same basic way.
9203
9204 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9205
9206 @subsection source and find commands
9207 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9208 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9209 @*Remember the parsing rules
9210 @enumerate
9211 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9212 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9213 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9214 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9215 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9216 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9217 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9218 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9219 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9220 @end enumerate
9221 @subsection format command
9222 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9223 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9224 @b{sprintf()}.
9225 @b{Example}
9226 @example
9227 set x 6
9228 set y 7
9229 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9230 @end example
9231 @enumerate
9232 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9233 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9234 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9235 @* Refer to Rule #1
9236 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9237 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9238 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9239 @end enumerate
9240 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9241 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9242 @example
9243 #1 Good
9244 proc someproc @{@} @{
9245 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9246 @}
9247 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9248 #2 Good - no variables
9249 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9250 #3 Good Curly Braces
9251 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9252 puts "Time: [date]"
9253 @}
9254 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9255 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9256 @end example
9257 @enumerate
9258 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9259 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9260 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9261 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9262 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9263 command.
9264 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9265 @*There are 4 examples:
9266 @enumerate
9267 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9268 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9269 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9270 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9271 @end enumerate
9272
9273 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9274 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9275 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9276
9277 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9278 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9279 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9280 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9281 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9282 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9283 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9284 @end enumerate
9285 @subsection Global Variables
9286 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9287 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9288 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9289 @example
9290 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9291 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9292 global x #Global variable X
9293 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9294 @}
9295 @end example
9296 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9297 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9298 @example
9299 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9300 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9301 # Create var name
9302 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9303 # Make it a global
9304 global $vn
9305 # Set it.
9306 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9307 @}
9308 @end example
9309 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9310 @example
9311 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9312 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9313 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9314 @}
9315 @end example
9316
9317 @include fdl.texi
9318
9319 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9320 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9321 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9322 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9323 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9324 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9325
9326 @printindex cp
9327
9328 @node Command and Driver Index
9329 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9330 @printindex fn
9331
9332 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)